blob: a1910dcfea0af9418851401fe1412e85ed9177ec [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +00002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2011
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
5# See file CREDITS for list of people who contributed to this
6# project.
7#
8# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
10# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of
11# the License, or (at your option) any later version.
12#
13# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16# GNU General Public License for more details.
17#
18# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
20# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston,
21# MA 02111-1307 USA
22#
23
24Summary:
25========
26
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000027This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000028Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
29processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
30initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
31code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000032
33The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
35header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000036support booting of Linux images.
37
38Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
39configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
40implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
41add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
42code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
43load and run it dynamically.
44
45
46Status:
47=======
48
49In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000051"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
52
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000053In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010054who contributed the specific port. The MAINTAINERS file lists board
55maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000057
58Where to get help:
59==================
60
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000061In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
62U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050063<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
64on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
65Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
66http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000067
68
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010069Where to get source code:
70=========================
71
72The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
73git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
74http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
75
76The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020077any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010078available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
79directory.
80
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010081Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010082ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
83
84
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000085Where we come from:
86===================
87
88- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000090- clean up code
91- make it easier to add custom boards
92- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
93- extend functions, especially:
94 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
95 * S-Record download
96 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020097 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000098- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000099- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000100- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +0200101- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000102
103
104Names and Spelling:
105===================
106
107The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
108"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
109in source files etc.). Example:
110
111 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
112
113File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
114
115 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
116
117 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
118
119Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
120the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
121
122 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
123 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000124
125
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000126Versioning:
127===========
128
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200129Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
130were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
131into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
132names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
133Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
134releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000135
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200136Examples:
137 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
138 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
139 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000140
141
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000142Directory Hierarchy:
143====================
144
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500145/arch Architecture specific files
146 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
147 /cpu CPU specific files
148 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
149 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000150 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200151 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
152 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500153 /arm925t Files specific to ARM 925 CPUs
154 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
155 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
156 /ixp Files specific to Intel XScale IXP CPUs
157 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
158 /s3c44b0 Files specific to Samsung S3C44B0 CPUs
159 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
160 /lib Architecture specific library files
161 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
162 /cpu CPU specific files
163 /lib Architecture specific library files
164 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
165 /cpu CPU specific files
166 /lib Architecture specific library files
Graeme Russfea25722011-04-13 19:43:28 +1000167 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500168 /cpu CPU specific files
169 /lib Architecture specific library files
170 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
171 /cpu CPU specific files
172 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
173 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
174 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
175 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
176 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
177 /lib Architecture specific library files
178 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
179 /cpu CPU specific files
180 /lib Architecture specific library files
181 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
182 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200183 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Xiangfu Liu80421fc2011-10-12 12:24:06 +0800184 /xburst Files specific to Ingenic XBurst CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500185 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000186 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
187 /cpu CPU specific files
188 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
189 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500190 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
191 /cpu CPU specific files
192 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200193 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500194 /cpu CPU specific files
195 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
196 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
197 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
198 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
199 /mpc8220 Files specific to Freescale MPC8220 CPUs
200 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
201 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
202 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
203 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
204 /lib Architecture specific library files
205 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
206 /cpu CPU specific files
207 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
208 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
209 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
210 /lib Architecture specific library files
211 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
212 /cpu CPU specific files
213 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
214 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
215 /lib Architecture specific library files
216/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
217/board Board dependent files
218/common Misc architecture independent functions
219/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
220/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
221/drivers Commonly used device drivers
222/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
223/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
224/include Header Files
225/lib Files generic to all architectures
226 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
227 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
228 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
229/net Networking code
230/post Power On Self Test
231/rtc Real Time Clock drivers
232/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000233
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000234Software Configuration:
235=======================
236
237Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
238rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
239
240There are two classes of configuration variables:
241
242* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
243 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
244 "CONFIG_".
245
246* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
247 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
248 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200249 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000250
251Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
252identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
253do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
254links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
255as an example here.
256
257
258Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
259---------------------------------------------------
260
261For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
262configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_config".
263
264Example: For a TQM823L module type:
265
266 cd u-boot
267 make TQM823L_config
268
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200269For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000270e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_config". And also configure the cogent
271directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
272
273
274Configuration Options:
275----------------------
276
277Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
278such information is kept in a configuration file
279"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
280
281Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
282"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
283
284
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000285Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
286kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
287build a config tool - later.
288
289
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000290The following options need to be configured:
291
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500292- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000293
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500294- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200295
296- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100297 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000298
299- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
300 Define exactly one of
301 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
302--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
303 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
304 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
305
306- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
307 Define exactly one of
308 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
309
310- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
311 Define one or more of
312 CONFIG_CMA302
313
314- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
315 Define one or more of
316 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200317 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000318 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
319
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000320- Board flavour: (if CONFIG_MPC8260ADS is defined)
321 CONFIG_ADSTYPE
322 Possible values are:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200323 CONFIG_SYS_8260ADS - original MPC8260ADS
324 CONFIG_SYS_8266ADS - MPC8266ADS
325 CONFIG_SYS_PQ2FADS - PQ2FADS-ZU or PQ2FADS-VR
326 CONFIG_SYS_8272ADS - MPC8272ADS
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000327
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530328- Marvell Family Member
329 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
330 multiple fs option at one time
331 for marvell soc family
332
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000333- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000334 Define exactly one of
335 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000336
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200337- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000338 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
339 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000340 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
341 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000342 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
343 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000344
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000345- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200346 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
347 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000348 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000349 See doc/README.MPC866
350
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200351 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000352
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000353 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
354 of relying on the correctness of the configured
355 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
356 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
357 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200358 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000359
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100360 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
361
362 Define this option if you want to enable the
363 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
364
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600365- 85xx CPU Options:
366 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
367
368 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
369 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
370 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
371
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500372 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
373
374 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
375 tree nodes for the given platform.
376
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100377- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200378 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100379
380 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
381 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
382 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
383
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200384 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200385
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100386 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
387 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200388 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100389 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200390
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200391- MIPS CPU options:
392 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
393
394 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
395 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
396 relocation.
397
398 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
399
400 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
401 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
402 Possible values are:
403 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
404 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
405 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
406 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
407 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
408 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
409 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
410 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
411
412 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
413
414 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
415 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
416
417 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
418
419 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
420 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
421 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
422
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000423- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000424 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
425
426 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
427 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
428 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
429 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
430 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
431 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
432 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000433 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100434 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000435 default environment.
436
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000437 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
438
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200439 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000440 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
441 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
442
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400443 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200444
445 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400446 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
447 concepts).
448
449 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
450 * New libfdt-based support
451 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500452 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400453
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200454 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
455 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
456 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
457 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200458 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600459 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200460
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200461 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
462 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500463
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600464 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
465
466 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
467 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000468
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500469 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
470
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200471 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500472 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
473
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200474 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
475
476 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
477 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
478 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
479 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
480 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
481 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
482
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000483 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
484
485 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
486 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
487 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
488 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
489 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
490 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
491 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
492
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100493- vxWorks boot parameters:
494
495 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
496 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
497 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
498
499 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
500 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
501 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
502 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
503
504 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
505
506 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
507
508 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
509 the defaults discussed just above.
510
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000511- Cache Configuration:
512 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
513 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
514 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
515
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000516- Cache Configuration for ARM:
517 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
518 controller
519 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
520 controller register space
521
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000522- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200523 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000524
525 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
526
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200527 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000528
529 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
530
531 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
532
533 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
534 the clock speed of the UARTs.
535
536 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
537
538 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
539 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
540 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
541
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000542 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
543
544 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
545 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
546 this variable to initialize the extra register.
547
548 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
549
550 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
551 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
552 variable to flush the UART at init time.
553
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000554
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000555- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000556 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
557 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
558 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
559 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000560
561 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
562 port routines must be defined elsewhere
563 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
564
565 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
566 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
567 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042, board/eltec/bab7xx)
568 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
569 (default big endian)
570 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
571 rectangle fill
572 (cf. smiLynxEM)
573 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
574 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
575 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
576 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000577 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
578 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000579 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
580 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000581 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000582 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
583 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
584 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
585 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
586 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
587 (i.e. i8042_getc)
588 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
589 (requires blink timer
590 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200591 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000592 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
593 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500594 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000595 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
596 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000597 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
598 linux_logo.h for logo.
599 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000600 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200601 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000602 the logo
603
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000604 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
605 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
606 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000607
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000608 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
609 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
610 the "silent" environment variable. See
611 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000612
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000613- Console Baudrate:
614 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
615 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200616 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
617 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000618
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100619- Console Rx buffer length
620 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
621 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100622 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100623 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
624 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
625 the SMC.
626
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000627- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200628 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
629 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
630 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
631 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
632 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
633 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
634 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200635 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200636 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000637
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200638 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
639 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000640
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000641- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
642 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
643 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
644
645 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
646 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
647 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
648 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
649 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
650 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
651 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
652 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
653 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
654 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
655 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
656 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
657
658- Autoboot Command:
659 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
660 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
661 define a command string that is automatically executed
662 when no character is read on the console interface
663 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
664
665 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000666 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
667 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
668 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000669
670 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000671 The value of these goes into the environment as
672 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
673 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200674 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000675
676- Pre-Boot Commands:
677 CONFIG_PREBOOT
678
679 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
680 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
681 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
682 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
683 entering interactive mode.
684
685 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
686 automatically generated or modified. For an example
687 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
688 modified when the user holds down a certain
689 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
690 booting the systems
691
692- Serial Download Echo Mode:
693 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
694 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
695 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
696 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
697 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
698 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
699 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
700
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500701- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000702 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
703 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200704 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000705
706- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500707 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
708 from the build by using the #include files
709 "config_cmd_all.h" and #undef'ing unwanted
710 commands, or using "config_cmd_default.h"
711 and augmenting with additional #define's
712 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000713
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500714 The default command configuration includes all commands
715 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000716
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500717 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500718 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
719 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
720 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
721 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
722 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
723 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
724 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500725 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500726 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
727 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
728 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600729 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
730 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
731 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
732 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500733 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
734 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500735 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500736 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
737 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500738 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500739 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500740 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
741 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT partition support
742 CONFIG_CMD_FDOS * Dos diskette Support
743 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
744 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -0500745 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +0000746 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500747 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
748 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
749 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
750 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
751 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all found images
752 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500753 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500754 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
755 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
756 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
757 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Mike Frysinger1ba7fd22010-12-26 12:34:49 -0500758 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500759 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
760 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400761 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM print md5 message digest
762 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500763 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
764 loop, loopw, mtest
765 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
766 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
767 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +0100768 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500769 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
770 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600771 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
772 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500773 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
774 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
775 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
776 host
777 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
778 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
779 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
780 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
781 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
782 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
783 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
784 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
785 (4xx only)
Alexander Hollerc6b1ee62011-01-18 09:48:08 +0100786 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400787 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +0200788 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500789 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +0000790 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +0000791 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Che-liang Chiouca366d02011-10-06 23:40:48 +0000792 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500793 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500794 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
795 CONFIG_CMD_FSL * Microblaze FSL support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000796
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000797
798 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
799 support you can write:
800
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500801 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
802 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000803
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400804 Other Commands:
805 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000806
807 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500808 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000809 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
810 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
811 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
812 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
813 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
814 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000815
816
817 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
818
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000819- Device tree:
820 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
821 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
822 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
823 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
824 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
825 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
826
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000827 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
828 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000829
830 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
831 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
832 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
833 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
834 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
835 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000836
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000837 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
838 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
839 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
840 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
841
842 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
843
844 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
845 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
846 still use the individual files if you need something more
847 exotic.
848
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000849- Watchdog:
850 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
851 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000852 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
853 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
854 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
855 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
856 available, then no further board specific code should
857 be needed to use it.
858
859 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
860 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
861 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
862 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000863
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000864- U-Boot Version:
865 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
866 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
867 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
868 version as printed by the "version" command.
869 This variable is readonly.
870
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000871- Real-Time Clock:
872
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500873 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000874 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
875 following options:
876
877 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
878 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Guennadi Liakhovetski7ce63702008-04-15 14:15:30 +0200879 CONFIG_RTC_MC13783 - use MC13783 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000880 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +0000881 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000882 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +0000883 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +0000884 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +0100885 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +0000886 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200887 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +0200888 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
889 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000890
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +0000891 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
892 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
893
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600894- GPIO Support:
895 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
896 CONFIG_PCA953X_INFO - enable pca953x info command
897
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +0000898 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
899 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
900 pins supported by a particular chip.
901
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600902 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
903 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
904
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000905- Timestamp Support:
906
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000907 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
908 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
909 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500910 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000911
912- Partition Support:
913 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION and/or CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION
richardretanubun07f3d782008-09-26 11:13:22 -0400914 and/or CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION and/or CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000915
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100916 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
917 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
918 least one partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000919
920- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000921 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
922 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000923
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +0000924 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
925 be performed by calling the function
926 ide_set_reset(int reset)
927 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000928
929- ATAPI Support:
930 CONFIG_ATAPI
931
932 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
933
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000934- LBA48 Support
935 CONFIG_LBA48
936
937 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +0100938 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000939 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
940 support disks up to 2.1TB.
941
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200942 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +0000943 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
944 Default is 32bit.
945
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000946- SCSI Support:
947 At the moment only there is only support for the
948 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
949 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
950
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200951 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
952 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
953 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000954 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
955 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200956 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000957
958- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +0000959 CONFIG_E1000
960 Support for Intel 8254x gigabit chips.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +0000961
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +0100962 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200963 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +0100964
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000965 CONFIG_EEPRO100
966 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200967 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000968 write routine for first time initialisation.
969
970 CONFIG_TULIP
971 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
972 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
973 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
974
975 CONFIG_NATSEMI
976 Support for National dp83815 chips.
977
978 CONFIG_NS8382X
979 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
980
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000981- NETWORK Support (other):
982
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +0100983 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
984 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
985
986 CONFIG_RMII
987 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
988
989 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
990 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
991 The driver doen't show link status messages.
992
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +0000993 CONFIG_DRIVER_LAN91C96
994 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
995
996 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
997 Define this to hold the physical address
998 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
999
1000 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1001 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1002
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001003 CONFIG_DRIVER_SMC91111
1004 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1005
1006 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1007 Define this to hold the physical address
1008 of the device (I/O space)
1009
1010 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1011 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1012
1013 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1014 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1015 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1016
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001017 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1018 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1019
1020 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1021 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1022 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1023 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1024 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1025 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1026 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1027 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1028
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001029 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001030 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1031
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001032 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001033 Define this to hold the physical address
1034 of the device (I/O space)
1035
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001036 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001037 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1038
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001039 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001040 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1041 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001042 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001043
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001044 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1045 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1046
1047 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1048 Define the number of ports to be used
1049
1050 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1051 Define the ETH PHY's address
1052
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001053 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1054 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1055
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001056- USB Support:
1057 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001058 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001059 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1060 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001061 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001062 storage devices.
1063 Note:
1064 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1065 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001066 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1067 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1068 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001069 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1070 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001071 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1072 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1073 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001074 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1075 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001076 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001077 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1078 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001079
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001080- USB Device:
1081 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1082 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1083 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001084 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001085 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1086 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001087 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001088 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1089 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1090 a Linux host by
1091 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1092 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1093 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1094 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001095
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001096 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1097 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001098
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001099 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1100 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1101 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001102
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001103 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001104 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1105 be set to usbtty.
1106
1107 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001108 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001109 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001110 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001111
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001112 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001113 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001114 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001115
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001116 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001117 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001118 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001119 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1120 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1121 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1122
1123 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1124 Define this string as the name of your company for
1125 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001126
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001127 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1128 Define this string as the name of your product
1129 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1130
1131 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1132 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1133 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1134 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1135 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001136
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001137 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1138 Define this as the unique Product ID
1139 for your device
1140 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001141
1142
1143- MMC Support:
1144 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1145 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1146 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1147 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001148 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1149 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001150
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001151 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1152 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1153
1154 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1155 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1156
1157 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1158 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1159
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001160- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1161 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1162 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1163 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1164
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001165 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1166 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001167 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1168
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001169 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001170 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1171 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1172
1173 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001174 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001175 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1176 have not defined a custom partition
1177
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001178- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1179 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
1180 Support for saving memory data as a file
1181 in FAT formatted partition
1182
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001183- Keyboard Support:
1184 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1185
1186 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1187 support
1188
1189 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1190 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1191 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1192 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1193 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1194
1195- Video support:
1196 CONFIG_VIDEO
1197
1198 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1199 video).
1200
1201 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1202
1203 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1204
1205 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001206 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001207 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1208 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1209 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001210
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001211 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001212 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001213 are possible:
1214 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001215 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001216
1217 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1218 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1219 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1220 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1221 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1222 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1223 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001224 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1225
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001226 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001227 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001228
1229
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001230 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001231 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001232 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1233 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1234
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001235 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001236 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001237 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1238 support, and should also define these other macros:
1239
1240 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1241 CONFIG_VIDEO
1242 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1243 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1244 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1245 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1246 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1247 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1248
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001249 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1250 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1251 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1252 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001253
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001254- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001255 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001256
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001257 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1258 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1259 defined in your board-specific files.
1260 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001261
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001262- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1263
1264 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1265 display); also select one of the supported displays
1266 by defining one of these:
1267
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001268 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1269
1270 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1271
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001272 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001273
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001274 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001275
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001276 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001277
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001278 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1279 Active, color, single scan.
1280
1281 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1282
1283 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001284 Active, color, single scan.
1285
1286 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1287
1288 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1289 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1290
1291 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1292
1293 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1294 Active, color, single scan.
1295
1296 CONFIG_HLD1045
1297
1298 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1299 Active, color, single scan.
1300
1301 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1302
1303 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1304 or
1305 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1306 or
1307 Hitachi SP14Q002
1308
1309 320x240. Black & white.
1310
1311 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001312 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001313
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001314- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001315
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001316 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1317 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1318 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001319 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001320 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1321 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1322 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1323 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001324
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001325 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1326
1327 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1328 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1329 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1330 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1331 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1332 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1333
1334 Example:
1335 setenv splashpos m,m
1336 => image at center of screen
1337
1338 setenv splashpos 30,20
1339 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1340
1341 setenv splashpos -10,m
1342 => vertically centered image
1343 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1344
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001345- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1346
1347 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1348 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1349 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1350
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001351- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1352
1353 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1354 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1355 bmp command.
1356
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001357- Compression support:
1358 CONFIG_BZIP2
1359
1360 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1361 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1362 compressed images are supported.
1363
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001364 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001365 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001366 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001367
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001368 CONFIG_LZMA
1369
1370 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1371 images is included.
1372
1373 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1374 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1375 formula:
1376
1377 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1378
1379 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1380 and Literal pos bits.
1381
1382 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1383 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1384 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1385 a very small buffer.
1386
1387 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1388 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001389 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001390
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001391- MII/PHY support:
1392 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1393
1394 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1395
1396 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1397
1398 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1399
1400 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1401
1402 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001403 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001404
1405 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1406
1407 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1408 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1409 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1410 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1411
1412 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1413
1414 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1415 command issued before MII status register can be read
1416
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001417- Ethernet address:
1418 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001419 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001420 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1421 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001422 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1423 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001424
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001425 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1426 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001427 is not determined automatically.
1428
1429- IP address:
1430 CONFIG_IPADDR
1431
1432 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001433 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001434 determined through e.g. bootp.
1435
1436- Server IP address:
1437 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1438
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001439 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001440 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
1441
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001442 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1443
1444 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1445 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1446
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001447- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1448 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1449
1450 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1451 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001452 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001453 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1454 multicast group.
1455
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001456- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1457 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1458
1459 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1460 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1461 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1462 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1463 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1464 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1465 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1466 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001467 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001468
1469 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1470 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1471 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1472 4th and following
1473 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1474
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001475- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001476 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1477 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001478
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001479 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1480 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1481 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1482 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1483 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1484 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1485 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1486 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1487 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1488 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1489 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1490 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001491
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001492 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1493 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001494
1495 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1496 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1497 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1498 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1499 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1500 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1501 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001502 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001503
1504 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1505 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1506 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001507 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001508 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1509 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001510
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001511 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1512
1513 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1514 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1515 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1516 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1517 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1518 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1519 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1520 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1521 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1522 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1523 this delay.
1524
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001525 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001526 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001527
1528 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1529
1530 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1531
1532 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1533 of the device.
1534
1535 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1536
1537 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1538 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001539 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001540
1541 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1542
1543 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1544 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1545
1546 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1547
1548 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1549
1550 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1551
1552 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1553
1554 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1555
1556 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1557
1558 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1559
1560 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1561 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1562
1563 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1564
1565 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1566
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001567- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
1568
1569 Several configurations allow to display the current
1570 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1571 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1572 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1573 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1574 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
1575 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
1576 feature in U-Boot.
1577
1578- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
1579
1580 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
1581 on those systems that support this (optional)
1582 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
1583
1584- I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C | CONFIG_SOFT_I2C
1585
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001586 These enable I2C serial bus commands. Defining either of
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001587 (but not both of) CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C will
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001588 include the appropriate I2C driver for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001589
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001590 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001591 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001592 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
1593 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001594 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001595
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001596 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001597
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001598 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C configures u-boot to use a software (aka
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001599 bit-banging) driver instead of CPM or similar hardware
1600 support for I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001601
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001602 There are several other quantities that must also be
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001603 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001604
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001605 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001606 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001607 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001608 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001609
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001610 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02001611 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001612 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
1613 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
1614 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001615
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05001616 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
1617
1618 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1619 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1620 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
1621 commands until the slave device responds.
1622
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001623 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001624
1625 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SOFT_I2C)
1626 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1627 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001628
1629 I2C_INIT
1630
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001631 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001632 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001633
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001634 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001635
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001636 I2C_PORT
1637
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001638 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
1639 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
1640 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001641
1642 I2C_ACTIVE
1643
1644 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1645 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1646 define can be null.
1647
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001648 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1649
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001650 I2C_TRISTATE
1651
1652 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1653 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1654 define can be null.
1655
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001656 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1657
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001658 I2C_READ
1659
1660 Code that returns TRUE if the I2C data line is high,
1661 FALSE if it is low.
1662
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001663 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1664
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001665 I2C_SDA(bit)
1666
1667 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1668 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1669
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001670 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001671 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001672 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001673
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001674 I2C_SCL(bit)
1675
1676 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1677 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1678
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001679 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001680 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001681 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001682
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001683 I2C_DELAY
1684
1685 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1686 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001687 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001688 like:
1689
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001690 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001691
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04001692 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
1693
1694 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
1695 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
1696 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
1697 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
1698
1699 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
1700 the generic GPIO functions.
1701
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001702 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001703
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001704 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1705 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1706 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
1707 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
1708 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
1709 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
1710 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
1711 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001712
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04001713 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
1714
1715 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
1716 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
1717 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
1718 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
1719 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
1720 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
1721 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
1722 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
1723
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001724 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
1725
1726 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
1727 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
1728 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
1729
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001730 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
1731
1732 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
1733 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
1734 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
1735 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
1736
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001737 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001738
1739 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05001740 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
1741 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
1742 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001743
1744 e.g.
1745 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001746 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001747
1748 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
1749
1750 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001751 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001752
1753 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
1754
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001755 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001756
1757 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
1758 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
1759
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001760 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001761
1762 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
1763 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
1764
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001765 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01001766
1767 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
1768 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
1769
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001770 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07001771
1772 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
1773 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
1774 specified DTT device.
1775
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001776 CONFIG_FSL_I2C
1777
1778 Define this option if you want to use Freescale's I2C driver in
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001779 drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001780
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001781 CONFIG_I2C_MUX
1782
1783 Define this option if you have I2C devices reached over 1 .. n
1784 I2C Muxes like the pca9544a. This option addes a new I2C
1785 Command "i2c bus [muxtype:muxaddr:muxchannel]" which adds a
1786 new I2C Bus to the existing I2C Busses. If you select the
1787 new Bus with "i2c dev", u-bbot sends first the commandos for
1788 the muxes to activate this new "bus".
1789
1790 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS must be also defined, to use this
1791 feature!
1792
1793 Example:
1794 Adding a new I2C Bus reached over 2 pca9544a muxes
1795 The First mux with address 70 and channel 6
1796 The Second mux with address 71 and channel 4
1797
1798 => i2c bus pca9544a:70:6:pca9544a:71:4
1799
1800 Use the "i2c bus" command without parameter, to get a list
1801 of I2C Busses with muxes:
1802
1803 => i2c bus
1804 Busses reached over muxes:
1805 Bus ID: 2
1806 reached over Mux(es):
1807 pca9544a@70 ch: 4
1808 Bus ID: 3
1809 reached over Mux(es):
1810 pca9544a@70 ch: 6
1811 pca9544a@71 ch: 4
1812 =>
1813
1814 If you now switch to the new I2C Bus 3 with "i2c dev 3"
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00001815 u-boot first sends the command to the mux@70 to enable
1816 channel 6, and then the command to the mux@71 to enable
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001817 the channel 4.
1818
1819 After that, you can use the "normal" i2c commands as
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00001820 usual to communicate with your I2C devices behind
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02001821 the 2 muxes.
1822
1823 This option is actually implemented for the bitbanging
1824 algorithm in common/soft_i2c.c and for the Hardware I2C
1825 Bus on the MPC8260. But it should be not so difficult
1826 to add this option to other architectures.
1827
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06001828 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
1829
1830 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
1831 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
1832 between writing the address pointer and reading the
1833 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
1834 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
1835 devices can use either method, but some require one or
1836 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06001837
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001838- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
1839
1840 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
1841 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
1842 D/As on the SACSng board)
1843
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09001844 CONFIG_SH_SPI
1845
1846 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
1847 only SH7757 is supported.
1848
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001849 CONFIG_SPI_X
1850
1851 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
1852 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
1853
1854 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
1855
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001856 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
1857 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
1858 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
1859 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
1860 defined, the board configuration must define several
1861 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
1862 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001863
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05001864 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
1865
1866 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
1867 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
1868 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
1869 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
1870 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
1871
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02001872 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
1873
1874 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
1875 SoCs. Currently only i.MX31 is supported.
1876
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01001877- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
1878
1879 Enables FPGA subsystem.
1880
1881 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
1882
1883 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
1884 (ALTERA, XILINX)
1885
1886 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
1887
1888 Enables support for FPGA family.
1889 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
1890
1891 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001892
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001893 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001894
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001895 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001896
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001897 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001898
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001899 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001900
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001901 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
1902 status by the configuration function. This option
1903 will require a board or device specific function to
1904 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001905
1906 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
1907
1908 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
1909 configuration driver.
1910
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001911 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001912 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
1913
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001914 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001915
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001916 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
1917 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
1918 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
1919 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001920
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001921 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001922
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001923 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
1924 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
1925 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001926 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001927
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001928 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001929
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001930 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001931 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001932
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001933 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001934
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001935 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001936 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001937
1938- Configuration Management:
1939 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
1940
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001941 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
1942 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001943
1944- Vendor Parameter Protection:
1945
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001946 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
1947 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001948 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001949 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
1950 protects these variables from casual modification by
1951 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
1952 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001953 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001954
1955 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
1956 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001957 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001958 these parameters.
1959
1960 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
1961 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001962 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001963 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
1964 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
1965 read-only.]
1966
1967- Protected RAM:
1968 CONFIG_PRAM
1969
1970 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
1971 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
1972 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
1973 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
1974 this default value by defining an environment
1975 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
1976 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
1977 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
1978 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
1979 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
1980 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
1981 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
1982
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01001983 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001984 saveenv
1985
1986 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
1987 either, which results in a memory region that will
1988 not be affected by reboots.
1989
1990 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
1991 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
1992 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
1993 following board configurations are known to be
1994 "pRAM-clean":
1995
1996 ETX094, IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
1997 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON, LANTEC,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02001998 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001999
2000- Error Recovery:
2001 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2002
2003 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2004 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2005 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002006 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002007 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2008 useful during development since you can try to debug
2009 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2010
2011 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2012
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002013 This variable defines the number of retries for
2014 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2015 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2016 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002017
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002018 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2019
2020 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2021
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002022- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002023 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002024
2025 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2026
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002027 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2028 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002029
2030
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002031 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002032
2033 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2034 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2035 powerful command line syntax like
2036 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2037 constructs ("shell scripts").
2038
2039 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2040 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2041
2042
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002043 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002044
2045 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2046 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2047 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2048
2049 Note:
2050
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002051 In the current implementation, the local variables
2052 space and global environment variables space are
2053 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2054 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2055 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2056 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2057 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002058
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002059 Global environment variables are those you use
2060 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2061 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2062 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002063
2064 To store commands and special characters in a
2065 variable, please use double quotation marks
2066 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2067 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2068 symbols.
2069
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002070- Commandline Editing and History:
2071 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2072
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002073 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002074 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002075
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002076- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002077 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2078
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002079 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2080 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002081 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002082
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002083 For example, place something like this in your
2084 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002085
2086 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2087 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2088 "myvar2=value2\0"
2089
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002090 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2091 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2092 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2093 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002094 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002095 You better know what you are doing here.
2096
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002097 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2098 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002099 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002100 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002101
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002102- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002103 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2104
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002105 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2106 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2107 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002108
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002109- SystemACE Support:
2110 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2111
2112 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2113 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002114 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002115 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002116
2117 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002118 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002119
2120 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2121 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2122
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002123- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2124 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2125
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002126 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002127 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002128 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002129 number generator is used.
2130
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002131 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2132 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2133 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2134
2135 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002136 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2137 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2138 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2139 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2140 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2141 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2142
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002143- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002144 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2145
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002146 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2147 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2148 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2149 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2150 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2151 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002152
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002153Legacy uImage format:
2154
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002155 Arg Where When
2156 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002157 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002158 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002159 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002160 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002161 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002162 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2163 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2164 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002165 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002166 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2167 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2168 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2169 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002170 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002171 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002172
2173 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2174 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2175 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2176 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2177 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2178 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2179 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002180 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002181 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2182 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2183
Peter Tyserea0364f2010-04-12 22:28:04 -05002184 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002185
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002186 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd542004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002187 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2188 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002189
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002190 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2191 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2192 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2193 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2194 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2195 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2196 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2197 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2198 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2199 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2200 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2201 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2202 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2203 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2204 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2205 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2206 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2207 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2208 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2209 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2210 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2211 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2212 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2213 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2214 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2215 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2216 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2217 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2218 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2219 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2220 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2221 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2222 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2223 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2224 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2225 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2226 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2227 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2228 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2229 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2230 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2231 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2232 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2233 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2234 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2235 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2236 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002237
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002238 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002239
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002240 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002241 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2242 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00002243
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002244 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
2245 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002246 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002247 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
2248 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2249 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002250 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2251 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002252 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002253
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002254FIT uImage format:
2255
2256 Arg Where When
2257 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2258 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2259 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2260 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2261 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2262 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002263 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002264 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2265 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2266 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2267 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2268 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002269 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2270 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002271 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2272 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2273 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2274 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2275 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2276 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2277 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2278 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2279
2280 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2281 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2282 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002283 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002284 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2285 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2286 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2287 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2288 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2289 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2290 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2291 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2292 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2293 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2294 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2295 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2296
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002297 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002298 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2299
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002300 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002301 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2302
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002303 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002304 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2305
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002306- Standalone program support:
2307 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2308
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002309 This option defines a board specific value for the
2310 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2311 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002312 settings.
2313
2314- Frame Buffer Address:
2315 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2316
2317 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
2318 address for frame buffer.
2319 Then system will reserve the frame buffer address to
2320 defined address instead of lcd_setmem (this function
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002321 grabs the memory for frame buffer by panel's size).
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002322
2323 Please see board_init_f function.
2324
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002325- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2326 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2327 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2328 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2329
2330 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2331 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2332
2333- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
2334 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
2335
2336 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
2337 Needed for mtdparts command support.
2338
2339 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
2340
2341 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
2342 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
2343
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002344- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002345 CONFIG_SPL
2346 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002347
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002348 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2349 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002350
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002351 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2352 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002353
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002354 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
2355 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002356
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002357 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
2358 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002359
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002360 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
2361 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002362
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002363 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
2364 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002365
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002366 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
2367 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002368
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002369 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
2370 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002371
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002372 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
2373 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002374
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002375 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
2376 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002377
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002378 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
2379 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002380
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002381 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
2382 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002383
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002384Modem Support:
2385--------------
2386
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02002387[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002388
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002389- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002390 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
2391
2392- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
2393 CONFIG_HWFLOW
2394
2395- Modem debug support:
2396 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
2397
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002398 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
2399 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002400
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002401- Interrupt support (PPC):
2402
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002403 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2404 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002405 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002406 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002407 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002408 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002409 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002410 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2411 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2412 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002413
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002414- General:
2415
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002416 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
2417 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
2418 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002419 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002420 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
2421 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
2422 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002423
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002424 If there are no modem init strings in the
2425 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
2426 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002427 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002428
2429 See also: doc/README.Modem
2430
2431
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002432Configuration Settings:
2433-----------------------
2434
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002435- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002436 undefine this when you're short of memory.
2437
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06002438- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
2439 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
2440
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002441- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002442 prompt for user input.
2443
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002444- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002445
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002446- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002447
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002448- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002449
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002450- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002451 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
2452 booted
2453
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002454- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002455 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
2456
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002457- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002458 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002459
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002460- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002461 If the board specific function
2462 extern int overwrite_console (void);
2463 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002464 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
2465
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002466- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002467 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002468
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002469- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002470 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
2471
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002472- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002473 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
2474 simple memory test.
2475
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002476- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002477 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002478
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002479- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00002480 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
2481 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
2482
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002483- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
2484 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002485 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002486 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002487 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
2488 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
2489 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002490 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002491 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01002492 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01002493
2494 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
2495 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
2496 be touched.
2497
2498 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
2499 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
2500 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
2501 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
2502 problems.
2503
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002504- CONFIG_SYS_TFTP_LOADADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002505 Default load address for network file downloads
2506
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002507- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002508 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
2509
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002510- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002511 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
2512
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002513- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002514 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
2515 Cogent motherboard)
2516
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002517- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002518 Physical start address of Flash memory.
2519
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002520- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002521 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
2522 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02002523 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002524 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002525
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002526- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002527 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
2528 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
2529 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
2530 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002531
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002532- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002533 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
2534
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002535- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002536 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
2537 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002538 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01002539 to adjust this setting to your needs.
2540
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002541- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002542 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
2543 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02002544 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
2545 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
2546 enviroment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
2547 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00002548 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
2549 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
2550 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
2551 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002552
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06002553- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
2554 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
2555 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
2556 is enabled.
2557
2558- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
2559 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
2560 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2561
2562- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
2563 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
2564 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
2565
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002566- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002567 Max number of Flash memory banks
2568
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002569- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002570 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
2571
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002572- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002573 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
2574
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002575- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002576 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
2577
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002578- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002579 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
2580
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002581- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002582 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
2583
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002584- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00002585 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
2586 instead of U-Boot software protection.
2587
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002588- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002589
2590 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
2591 without this option such a download has to be
2592 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
2593 copy from RAM to flash.
2594
2595 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
2596 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002597 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
2598 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002599 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
2600
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002601- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002602 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002603 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
2604
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02002605- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00002606 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
2607 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002608
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01002609- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
2610 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
2611 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
2612 to the MTD layer.
2613
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002614- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02002615 Use buffered writes to flash.
2616
2617- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
2618 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
2619 write commands.
2620
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002621- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01002622 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
2623 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
2624 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
2625 optionally available.
2626
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05002627- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
2628 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
2629 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
2630 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
2631
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002632- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002633 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
2634 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002635 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
2636 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002637 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00002638 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
2639
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002640- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
2641
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02002642 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
2643 internally to store the environment settings. The default
2644 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
2645 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
2646 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02002647
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002648The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
2649of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
2650following configurations:
2651
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00002652- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
2653
2654 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
2655 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
2656
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02002657- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002658
2659 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
2660
2661 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
2662 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
2663 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
2664 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
2665 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
2666 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
2667 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
2668 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
2669 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
2670 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
2671 between U-Boot and the environment.
2672
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002673 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002674
2675 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
2676 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
2677 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
2678 for this sector is given here.
2679
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002680 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002681
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002682 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002683
2684 This is just another way to specify the start address of
2685 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002686 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002687
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002688 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002689
2690 Size of the sector containing the environment.
2691
2692
2693 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
2694 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
2695 the environment.
2696
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002697 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002698
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02002699 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002700 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002701 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
2702 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
2703
2704 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
2705 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
2706 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
2707 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
2708 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
2709 updating the environment in flash makes it always
2710 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
2711 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
2712 RAM, your target system will be dead.
2713
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002714 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
2715 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002716
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002717 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002718 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00002719 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002720 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002721
2722BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
2723source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
2724accordingly!
2725
2726
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02002727- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002728
2729 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
2730 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
2731 environment.
2732
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002733 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
2734 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002735
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002736 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002737 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
2738 can just be read and written to, without any special
2739 provision.
2740
2741BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
2742in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002743console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002744U-Boot will hang.
2745
2746Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
2747environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
2748keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
2749to save the current settings.
2750
2751
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02002752- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002753
2754 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
2755 device and a driver for it.
2756
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002757 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
2758 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002759
2760 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
2761 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
2762
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002763 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002764 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
2765 The default address is zero.
2766
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002767 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002768 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
2769 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
2770 would require six bits.
2771
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002772 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002773 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002774 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002775
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002776 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002777 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
2778 that this is NOT the chip address length!
2779
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002780 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00002781 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
2782 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
2783 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
2784 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
2785 byte chips.
2786
2787 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
2788 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
2789 in the chip address.
2790
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002791 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002792 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
2793
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01002794 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
2795 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
2796 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
2797
2798 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
2799 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
2800 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
2801 EEPROM. For example:
2802
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +02002803 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS "pca9547:70:d\0"
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01002804
2805 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
2806 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002807
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02002808- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00002809
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002810 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00002811 want to use for the environment.
2812
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002813 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
2814 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
2815 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00002816
2817 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
2818 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
2819 at the specified address.
2820
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02002821- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00002822
2823 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
2824 for the environment.
2825
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002826 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
2827 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00002828
2829 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05002830 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
2831 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00002832
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05002833 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01002834
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02002835 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05002836 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
2837 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
2838 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
2839 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01002840
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05002841 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
2842
2843 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
2844 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
2845 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
2846 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
2847 the range to be avoided.
2848
2849 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
2850
2851 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
2852 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
2853 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
2854 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
2855 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01002856
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02002857- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
2858
2859 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
2860 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
2861 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
2862
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002863- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002864
2865 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
2866 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
2867 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
2868 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
2869 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
2870 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
2871 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
2872
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07002873Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002874has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02002875created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002876until then to read environment variables.
2877
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00002878The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
2879is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
2880with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
2881necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
2882"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
2883have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002884
2885Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
2886the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00002887use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002888
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002889- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00002890 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00002891
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002892 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00002893 also needs to be defined.
2894
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002895- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00002896 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002897
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08002898- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
2899 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
2900 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
2901 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
2902 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
2903 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
2904
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002905Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00002906---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002907
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002908- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002909 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
2910
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002911- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002912 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002913
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00002914 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
2915 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
2916 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002917
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05002918- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
2919 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
2920 PowerPC SOCs.
2921
2922- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
2923 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
2924 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
2925
2926 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
2927 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
2928
2929- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
2930 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
2931 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
2932 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
2933 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
2934 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
2935 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
2936
2937 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
2938 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
2939
2940- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002941 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
2942 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05002943 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
2944 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
2945
2946- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
2947 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
2948 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
2949 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
2950
2951- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
2952 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
2953 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
2954
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002955- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002956 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002957
2958 the default drive number (default value 0)
2959
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002960 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002961
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002962 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002963 (default value 1)
2964
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002965 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002966
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002967 defines the offset of register from address. It
2968 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002969 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002970
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002971 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
2972 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002973 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002974
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002975 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002976 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
2977 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
2978 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
2979 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00002980
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00002981- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
2982 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
2983 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
2984 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
2985 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
2986 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
2987 is requierd.
2988
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002989- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00002990 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00002991 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002992
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002993- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002994
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002995 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002996 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
2997 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
2998 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
2999 will become available only after programming the
3000 memory controller and running certain initialization
3001 sequences.
3002
3003 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
3004 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
3005 - MPC824X: data cache
3006 - PPC4xx: data cache
3007
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003008- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003009
3010 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003011 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3012 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003013 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003014 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003015 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
3016 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3017 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003018
3019 Note:
3020 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3021 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003022 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003023 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3024 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3025
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003026- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003027
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003028- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003029
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003030- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003031
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003032- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003033
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003034- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003035
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003036- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003037
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003038- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003039 SDRAM timing
3040
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003041- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003042 periodic timer for refresh
3043
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003044- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003045
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003046- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3047 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3048 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3049 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003050 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3051
3052- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003053 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3054 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003055 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3056
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003057- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
3058 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003059 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
3060 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
3061
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003062- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003063 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3064 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
3065
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003066- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01003067 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3068 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
3069
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003070- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003071 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3072 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
3073
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003074- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003075 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
3076 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
3077 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
3078
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003079- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003080 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
3081 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
3082 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
3083 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00003084
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003085- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3086 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
3087 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
3088 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3089 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
3090 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
3091 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
3092 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003093 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00003094
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01003095- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
3096 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
3097 required.
3098
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003099- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3100 Chip has SRIO or not
3101
3102- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3103 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3104
3105- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3106 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3107
3108- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3109 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3110
3111- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3112 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3113
3114- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3115 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3116
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003117- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_16
3118 Defined to tell the NDFC that the NAND chip is using a
3119 16 bit bus.
3120
3121- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3122 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3123 a default value will be used.
3124
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003125- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003126 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3127 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3128
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003129 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3130 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3131
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003132- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003133 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3134 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3135 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003136
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003137- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3138 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3139 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3140 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3141 header files or board specific files.
3142
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003143- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3144 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3145
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003146- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003147 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3148 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003149
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003150- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
3151 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
3152
3153- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
3154 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00003155 to the given FEC; i. e.
3156 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003157 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
3158
3159 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
3160
3161- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
3162 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
3163 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
3164
3165- CONFIG_RMII
3166 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3167 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3168 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3169
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003170- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3171 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3172 The syntax is:
3173
3174 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3175
3176 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3177 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3178 area should have.
3179
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003180- CONFIG_LOOPW
3181 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003182 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003183
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003184- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3185 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3186 "md/mw" commands.
3187 Examples:
3188
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003189 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003190 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3191
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003192 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003193 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3194
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003195 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003196 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003197
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003198- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003199 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003200 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3201 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3202 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003203
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003204 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3205 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3206 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3207 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003208
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003209- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003210 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3211 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3212 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003213
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00003214- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
3215 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
3216 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
3217 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
3218 conditions but may increase the binary size.
3219
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003220Building the Software:
3221======================
3222
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003223Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3224and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3225all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3226(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3227recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3228which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003229
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003230If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3231have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3232you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3233Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3234necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003235
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003236 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3237 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003238
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003239Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3240 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3241 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3242 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3243
3244 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3245
3246 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3247 be executed on computers running Windows.
3248
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003249U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3250sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003251is done by typing:
3252
3253 make NAME_config
3254
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003255where "NAME_config" is the name of one of the existing configu-
3256rations; see the main Makefile for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003257
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003258Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3259 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3260 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3261 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003262 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003263
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003264 make TQM823L_config
3265 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003266
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003267 make TQM823L_LCD_config
3268 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003269
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003270 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003271
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003272
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003273Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
3274images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003275
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003276- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
3277- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
3278- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003279
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003280By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
3281in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
3282this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
3283
32841. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
3285
3286 make O=/tmp/build distclean
3287 make O=/tmp/build NAME_config
3288 make O=/tmp/build all
3289
32902. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
3291
3292 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
3293 make distclean
3294 make NAME_config
3295 make all
3296
3297Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
3298variable.
3299
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003300
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003301Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
3302for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
3303native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003304
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003305
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003306If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
3307to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
3308steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003309
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000033101. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
3311 "Makefile" and to the "MAKEALL" script, using the existing
3312 entries as examples. Note that here and at many other places
3313 boards and other names are listed in alphabetical sort order. Please
3314 keep this order.
33152. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
3316 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
3317 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
33183. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
3319 your board
33203. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
3321 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
33224. Run "make <board>_config" with your new name.
33235. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
3324 to be installed on your target system.
33256. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
3326 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003327
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003328
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003329Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
3330==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003331
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003332If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
3333or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003334provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
3335the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003336official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003337
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003338But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
3339cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003340the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
3341just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003342for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
3343select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
3344environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
3345you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003346
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003347 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003348
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003349or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003350
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003351 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003352
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003353When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
3354U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
3355setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
3356built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
3357<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
3358location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
3359variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003360
3361 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
3362 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
3363 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
3364
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003365With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
3366log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
3367during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003368
3369
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003370See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003371
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003372
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003373Monitor Commands - Overview:
3374============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003375
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003376go - start application at address 'addr'
3377run - run commands in an environment variable
3378bootm - boot application image from memory
3379bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
3380tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
3381 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
3382 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00003383tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003384rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
3385diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
3386loads - load S-Record file over serial line
3387loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
3388md - memory display
3389mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
3390nm - memory modify (constant address)
3391mw - memory write (fill)
3392cp - memory copy
3393cmp - memory compare
3394crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05003395i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003396sspi - SPI utility commands
3397base - print or set address offset
3398printenv- print environment variables
3399setenv - set environment variables
3400saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
3401protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
3402erase - erase FLASH memory
3403flinfo - print FLASH memory information
3404bdinfo - print Board Info structure
3405iminfo - print header information for application image
3406coninfo - print console devices and informations
3407ide - IDE sub-system
3408loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003409loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003410mtest - simple RAM test
3411icache - enable or disable instruction cache
3412dcache - enable or disable data cache
3413reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
3414echo - echo args to console
3415version - print monitor version
3416help - print online help
3417? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003418
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003419
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003420Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
3421========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003422
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003423TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003424
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003425For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003426
3427
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003428Environment Variables:
3429======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003430
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003431U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
3432can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003433
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003434Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
3435"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
3436without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
3437environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
3438working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
3439environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003440
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003441Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
3442
3443List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003444
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003445 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003446
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003447 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003448
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003449 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003450
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003451 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003452
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003453 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003454
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003455 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3456 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3457 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
3458 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
3459 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
3460 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003461 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
3462 bootm_mapsize.
3463
3464 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
3465 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
3466 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
3467 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
3468 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
3469 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
3470 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003471
3472 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
3473 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
3474 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
3475 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
3476 environment variable.
3477
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02003478 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
3479 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
3480 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
3481
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003482 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
3483 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
3484 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
3485 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003486
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003487 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
3488 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
3489 be automatically started (by internally calling
3490 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003491
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003492 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
3493 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
3494 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
3495 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
3496 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003497
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04003498 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
3499 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
3500 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
3501 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
3502 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
3503 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
3504 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
3505 must be accessible by the kernel.
3506
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00003507 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
3508 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
3509 defined.
3510
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00003511 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
3512 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
3513 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
3514 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
3515 it must be saved and board must be reset.
3516
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003517 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
3518 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
3519 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
3520 is usually what you want since it allows for
3521 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
3522 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003523 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003524 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
3525 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
3526 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
3527 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003528
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003529 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
3530 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
3531 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
3532 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
3533 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
3534 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003535
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003536 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003537
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003538 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
3539 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
3540 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
3541 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
3542 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
3543 boot time on your system, but requires that this
3544 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00003545
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003546 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003547
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003548 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
3549 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003550
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003551 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003552
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003553 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00003554
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003555 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003556
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003557 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003558
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003559 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003560
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003561 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003562
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00003563 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
3564 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003565
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02003566 => setenv ethact FEC
3567 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
3568 => setenv ethact SCC
3569 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003570
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01003571 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
3572 available network interfaces.
3573 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
3574
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003575 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003576 either succeed or fail without retrying.
3577 When set to "once" the network operation will
3578 fail when all the available network interfaces
3579 are tried once without success.
3580 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
3581 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003582
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01003583 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01003584
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003585 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003586 UDP source port.
3587
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003588 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
3589 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
3590
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01003591 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
3592 we use the TFTP server's default block size
3593
3594 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
3595 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
3596 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
3597 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
3598 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
3599 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
3600 with unreliable TFTP servers.
3601
3602 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003603 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003604 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003605
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00003606The following image location variables contain the location of images
3607used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
3608not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
3609variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
3610server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
3611loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
3612flash or offset in NAND flash.
3613
3614*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
3615boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
3616boards use these variables for other purposes.
3617
3618Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
3619----- --------- ----------- --------------
3620u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
3621Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
3622device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
3623ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
3624
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003625The following environment variables may be used and automatically
3626updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
3627depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003628
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003629 bootfile - see above
3630 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
3631 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
3632 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
3633 hostname - Target hostname
3634 ipaddr - see above
3635 netmask - Subnet Mask
3636 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
3637 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003638
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00003639
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003640There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003641
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003642 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
3643 as type string and/or serial number
3644 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003645
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003646These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
3647the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
3648once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003649
3650
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003651Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003652
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003653 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
3654 with the "version" command. This variable is
3655 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003656
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003657
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003658Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
3659only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003660
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00003661
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003662Command Line Parsing:
3663=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00003664
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003665There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
3666the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00003667
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003668Old, simple command line parser:
3669--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003670
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003671- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
3672- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01003673- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003674- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
3675 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01003676 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003677- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
3678 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003679
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003680Hush shell:
3681-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003682
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003683- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
3684 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
3685 until...do...done, ...
3686- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
3687 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
3688 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
3689 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003690
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003691General rules:
3692--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003693
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003694(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
3695 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
3696 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
3697 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003698
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003699(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003700 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003701 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
3702 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003703
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003704Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
3705=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003706
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003707Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003708such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
3709"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003710
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003711Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
3712MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
3713"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003714
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003715If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
3716in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
3717ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
3718variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00003719
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003720o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
3721 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003722
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003723o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
3724 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
3725 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003726
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003727o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
3728 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003729
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003730o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
3731 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
3732 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003733
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003734o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
3735 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003736
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07003737If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
3738will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
3739may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
3740The naming convention is as follows:
3741"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003742
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003743Image Formats:
3744==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003745
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01003746U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
3747images in two formats:
3748
3749New uImage format (FIT)
3750-----------------------
3751
3752Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
3753to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
3754components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
3755SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
3756
3757
3758Old uImage format
3759-----------------
3760
3761Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
3762preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
3763details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003764
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003765* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
3766 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05003767 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
3768 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
3769 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02003770* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003771 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
3772 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003773* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
3774* Load Address
3775* Entry Point
3776* Image Name
3777* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003778
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003779The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
3780and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
3781CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003782
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003783
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003784Linux Support:
3785==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003786
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003787Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
3788easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
3789U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003790
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003791U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
3792special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
3793"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
3794instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
3795serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003796
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003797- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
3798 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
3799 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003800
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003801- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
3802 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003803
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003804- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
3805 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
3806 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
3807 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
3808 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
3809 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003810
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003811
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003812Linux HOWTO:
3813============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003814
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003815Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
3816---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003817
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003818U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
3819configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
3820(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
3821Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003822
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003823But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003824
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003825Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
3826include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02003827Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
3828and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003829as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003830
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003831
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003832Configuring the Linux kernel:
3833-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003834
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003835No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
3836device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003837
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003838
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003839Building a Linux Image:
3840-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003841
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003842With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
3843not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
3844"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
3845U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
3846which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
3847100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003848
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003849Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003850
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003851 make TQM850L_config
3852 make oldconfig
3853 make dep
3854 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003855
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003856The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
3857encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
3858CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003859
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003860* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003861
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003862* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003863
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003864 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
3865 -R .note -R .comment \
3866 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003867
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003868* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003869
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003870 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003871
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003872* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003873
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003874 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
3875 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
3876 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003877
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003878
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003879The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
3880with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
3881combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
3882byte header containing information about target architecture,
3883operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
3884stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003885
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003886"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
3887print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003888
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003889In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
3890contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
3891checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003892
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003893 tools/mkimage -l image
3894 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003895
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003896The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
3897from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003898
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003899 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
3900 -n name -d data_file image
3901 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
3902 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
3903 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
3904 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
3905 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
3906 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
3907 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
3908 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00003909
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00003910Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
3911address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
3912kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003913
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003914- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
3915- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003916
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003917So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003918
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003919 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
3920 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003921 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003922 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
3923 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
3924 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
3925 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
3926 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
3927 Load Address: 0x00000000
3928 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003929
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003930To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003931
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003932 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
3933 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
3934 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
3935 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
3936 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
3937 Load Address: 0x00000000
3938 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003939
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003940NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
3941speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
3942needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
3943need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003944
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003945 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003946 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
3947 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003948 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003949 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
3950 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
3951 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
3952 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
3953 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
3954 Load Address: 0x00000000
3955 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003956
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003957
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003958Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
3959when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00003960
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003961 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
3962 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
3963 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
3964 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
3965 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
3966 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
3967 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
3968 Load Address: 0x00000000
3969 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00003970
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00003971
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003972Installing a Linux Image:
3973-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00003974
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003975To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
3976you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00003977
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003978 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00003979
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003980The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
3981image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
3982address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
3983specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
3984command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003985
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003986Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
3987TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003988
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003989 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003990
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003991 .......... done
3992 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003993
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003994 => loads 40100000
3995 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
3996 ~>examples/image.srec
3997 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
3998 ...
3999 15989 15990 15991 15992
4000 [file transfer complete]
4001 [connected]
4002 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004003
4004
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004005You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004006this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004007corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004008
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004009 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004010
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004011 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4012 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4013 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4014 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4015 Load Address: 00000000
4016 Entry Point: 0000000c
4017 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004018
4019
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004020Boot Linux:
4021-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004022
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004023The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4024memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4025of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4026parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4027"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004028
4029
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004030 => printenv bootargs
4031 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004032
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004033 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004034
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004035 => printenv bootargs
4036 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004037
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004038 => bootm 40020000
4039 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4040 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4041 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4042 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4043 Load Address: 00000000
4044 Entry Point: 0000000c
4045 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4046 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4047 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4048 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4049 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4050 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4051 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4052 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004053
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004054If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004055the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4056format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004057
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004058 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004059
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004060 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4061 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4062 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4063 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4064 Load Address: 00000000
4065 Entry Point: 0000000c
4066 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004067
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004068 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4069 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4070 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4071 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4072 Load Address: 00000000
4073 Entry Point: 00000000
4074 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004075
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004076 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4077 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4078 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4079 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4080 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4081 Load Address: 00000000
4082 Entry Point: 0000000c
4083 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4084 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4085 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4086 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4087 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4088 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4089 Load Address: 00000000
4090 Entry Point: 00000000
4091 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4092 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4093 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4094 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4095 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4096 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4097 ...
4098 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4099 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004100
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004101 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004102
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004103Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4104-----------
4105
4106First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4107titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4108following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4109flat device tree:
4110
4111=> print oftaddr
4112oftaddr=0x300000
4113=> print oft
4114oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4115=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4116Speed: 1000, full duplex
4117Using TSEC0 device
4118TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4119Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4120Load address: 0x300000
4121Loading: #
4122done
4123Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4124=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4125Speed: 1000, full duplex
4126Using TSEC0 device
4127TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4128Filename 'uImage'.
4129Load address: 0x200000
4130Loading:############
4131done
4132Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4133=> print loadaddr
4134loadaddr=200000
4135=> print oftaddr
4136oftaddr=0x300000
4137=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4138## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004139 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4140 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4141 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004142 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004143 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004144 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4145 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4146Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4147Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4148Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4149[snip]
4150
4151
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004152More About U-Boot Image Types:
4153------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004154
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004155U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004156
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004157 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4158 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4159 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4160 the Standalone Program.
4161 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4162 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4163 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4164 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4165 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4166 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4167 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4168 being started.
4169 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4170 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4171 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4172 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4173 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4174 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004175
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004176 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4177 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4178 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4179 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4180 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4181 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004182
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004183 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4184 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4185 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004186
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004187 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4188 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4189 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4190 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004191
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004192
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004193Standalone HOWTO:
4194=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004195
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004196One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4197run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4198U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004199
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004200Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004201
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004202"Hello World" Demo:
4203-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004204
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004205'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4206application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4207It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4208like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004209
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004210 => loads
4211 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4212 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
4213 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4214 [file transfer complete]
4215 [connected]
4216 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004217
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004218 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
4219 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4220 Hello World
4221 argc = 7
4222 argv[0] = "40004"
4223 argv[1] = "Hello"
4224 argv[2] = "World!"
4225 argv[3] = "This"
4226 argv[4] = "is"
4227 argv[5] = "a"
4228 argv[6] = "test."
4229 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
4230 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004231
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004232 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004233
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004234Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
4235handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
4236Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
4237The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
4238character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
4239controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004240
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004241 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
4242 b - enable interrupts and start timer
4243 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
4244 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004245
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004246 => loads
4247 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4248 ~>examples/timer.srec
4249 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4250 [file transfer complete]
4251 [connected]
4252 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004253
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004254 => go 40004
4255 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4256 TIMERS=0xfff00980
4257 Using timer 1
4258 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004259
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004260Hit 'b':
4261 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
4262 Enabling timer
4263Hit '?':
4264 [q, b, e, ?] ........
4265 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
4266Hit '?':
4267 [q, b, e, ?] .
4268 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
4269Hit '?':
4270 [q, b, e, ?] .
4271 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
4272Hit '?':
4273 [q, b, e, ?] .
4274 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
4275Hit 'e':
4276 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
4277Hit 'q':
4278 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004279
4280
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004281Minicom warning:
4282================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004283
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004284Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
4285"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
4286consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
4287Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
4288especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
4289use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command).
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004290
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004291Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
4292configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004293
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004294 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
4295 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
4296 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00004297
4298
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004299NetBSD Notes:
4300=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004301
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004302Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
4303(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004304
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004305Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
4306NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
4307need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
4308Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
4309attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
4310missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004311
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004312 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
4313 # mkdir powerpc
4314 # ln -s powerpc machine
4315 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
4316 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004317
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004318Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
4319and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004320
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004321Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
4322stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
4323proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
4324tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00004325meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004326
4327
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004328Implementation Internals:
4329=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004330
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004331The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
4332implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
4333inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
4334hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004335
4336
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004337Initial Stack, Global Data:
4338---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004339
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004340The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
4341starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
4342system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
4343This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
4344is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
4345at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
4346options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
4347models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
4348MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
4349locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004350
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004351 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004352 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004353
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004354 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
4355 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
4356 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
4357 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004358
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004359 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
4360 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
4361 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
4362 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
4363 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004364 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004365 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
4366 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004367
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004368 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
4369 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004370 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004371 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
4372 board designers haven't used it for something that would
4373 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
4374 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004375
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004376 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004377 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
4378 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02004379 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004380 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
4381 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
4382 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
4383 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
4384 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004385
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004386 -Chris Hallinan
4387 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004388
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004389It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
4390code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004391
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004392* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
4393 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004394
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004395* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004396 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
4397 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004398
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004399* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
4400 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004401
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004402Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
4403normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
4404turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
4405simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
4406functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
4407functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
4408the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
4409place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
4410reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004411
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004412When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
4413relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
4414GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004415
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004416For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
4417 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004418 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004419 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
4420 R5-R10: parameter passing
4421 R13: small data area pointer
4422 R30: GOT pointer
4423 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004424
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01004425 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
4426 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
4427 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004428
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01004429 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004430
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004431 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
4432 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
4433 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
4434 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
4435 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
4436 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004437
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00004438On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05004439 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
4440
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00004441 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05004442
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004443On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004444
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004445 R0: function argument word/integer result
4446 R1-R3: function argument word
4447 R9: GOT pointer
4448 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking if enabled)
4449 R11: argument (frame) pointer
4450 R12: temporary workspace
4451 R13: stack pointer
4452 R14: link register
4453 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004454
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004455 ==> U-Boot will use R8 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004456
Thomas Chou0df01fd32010-05-21 11:08:03 +08004457On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
4458 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
4459
4460 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
4461
4462 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
4463 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
4464
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004465On NDS32, the following registers are used:
4466
4467 R0-R1: argument/return
4468 R2-R5: argument
4469 R15: temporary register for assembler
4470 R16: trampoline register
4471 R28: frame pointer (FP)
4472 R29: global pointer (GP)
4473 R30: link register (LP)
4474 R31: stack pointer (SP)
4475 PC: program counter (PC)
4476
4477 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
4478
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02004479NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
4480or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004481
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004482Memory Management:
4483------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004484
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004485U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
4486MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004487
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004488The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
4489controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
4490memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
4491physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004492
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004493U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
4494TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
4495booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
4496to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004497memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004498configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
4499Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004500
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004501Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
4502of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004503
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004504So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
4505this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004506
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004507 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
4508 :
4509 0x0000 1FFF
4510 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
4511 :
4512 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004513
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004514 :
4515 :
4516 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
4517 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
4518 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
4519 :
4520 0x00FD FFFF
4521 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
4522 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
4523 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
4524 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004525
4526
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004527System Initialization:
4528----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004529
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004530In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004531(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004532configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
4533To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
4534To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
4535initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
4536which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
4537part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
4538the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004539
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004540Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
4541preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
4542(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
4543on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
4544programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
4545simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
4546banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004547
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004548When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
4549different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
4550bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
45510x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
4552contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004553
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004554Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
4555and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
4556Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
4557pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004558
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004559Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
4560until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
4561running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
4562new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004563
4564
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004565U-Boot Porting Guide:
4566----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004567
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004568[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
4569list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004570
4571
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004572int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004573{
4574 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004575
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004576 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
4577 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004578
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004579 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004580 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004581 return 0;
4582 }
4583
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004584 Download latest U-Boot source;
4585
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004586 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004587
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004588 if (clueless)
4589 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004590
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004591 while (learning) {
4592 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004593 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
4594 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004595 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004596 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004597 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004598
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004599 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
4600 Buy a BDI3000;
4601 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004602 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004603
4604 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
4605 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
4606 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
4607 } else {
4608 Create your own board support subdirectory;
4609 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004610 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004611 Edit new board/<myboard> files
4612 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004613
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04004614 while (!accepted) {
4615 while (!running) {
4616 do {
4617 Add / modify source code;
4618 } until (compiles);
4619 Debug;
4620 if (clueless)
4621 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
4622 }
4623 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
4624 if (reasonable critiques)
4625 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
4626 else
4627 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004628 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004629
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004630 return 0;
4631}
4632
4633void no_more_time (int sig)
4634{
4635 hire_a_guru();
4636}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004637
4638
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004639Coding Standards:
4640-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004641
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004642All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02004643coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004644"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004645
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02004646Source files originating from a different project (for example the
4647MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
4648reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
4649sources.
4650
4651Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
4652Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
4653in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004654
4655Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
4656- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004657- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004658- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004659- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004660- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
4661
4662Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
4663with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004664
4665
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004666Submitting Patches:
4667-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004668
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004669Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
4670establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
4671may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004672
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02004673Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004674
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004675Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
4676see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
4677
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004678When you send a patch, please include the following information with
4679it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004680
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004681* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
4682 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
4683 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004684
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004685* For new features: a description of the feature and your
4686 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004687
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004688* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
4689
4690* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
4691
4692* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add this
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004693 board to the MAINTAINERS file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004694
4695* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
4696 document these in the README file.
4697
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004698* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
4699 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00004700 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004701 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
4702 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004703
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004704 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
4705 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
4706 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004707
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004708 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
4709 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
4710 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
4711 affected files).
4712
4713 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
4714 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004715
4716* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
4717 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
4718
4719* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
4720 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
4721
4722
4723Notes:
4724
4725* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
4726 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
4727 for any of the boards.
4728
4729* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
4730 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
4731 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
4732
4733* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
4734 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
4735 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
4736 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
4737 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
4738 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00004739
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01004740* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
4741 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
4742 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
4743 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.